docs: added note for increasing gdb remotetimeout when using the "gdb_port pipe"...
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB JLINK based
453 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
454 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
460 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
464 @end itemize
465
466 @section USB RLINK based
467 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
468 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
469 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
470
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
476 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
477 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
478 @end itemize
479
480 @section USB ST-LINK based
481 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
482 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
483
484 @itemize @bullet
485 @item @b{ST-LINK}
486 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
487 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
488 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
489 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
490 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
491 @end itemize
492
493 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
494 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
495 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
496 @itemize @bullet
497 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
498 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
499 @end itemize
500
501 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
502 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
503 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
504 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
505
506 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
507 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
508 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
509
510 @section USB Other
511 @itemize @bullet
512 @item @b{USBprog}
513 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
514
515 @item @b{USB - Presto}
516 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
517
518 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
519 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
520
521 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
522 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
523
524 @item @b{Buspirate}
525 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
526
527 @item @b{opendous}
528 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
529
530 @item @b{estick}
531 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
532
533 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
534 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
535 @end itemize
536
537 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
538
539 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
540 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
541 these on the market.
542
543 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
544 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
545 of USB-based ones.
546
547 @itemize @bullet
548
549 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
550 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
551
552 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
553 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
554 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
555
556 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Wiggler2}
560 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
561
562 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
563 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
564
565 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
566 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
567
568 @item @b{arm-jtag}
569 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
570
571 @item @b{chameleon}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
573
574 @item @b{Triton}
575 @* Unknown.
576
577 @item @b{Lattice}
578 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
579 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
580
581 @item @b{flashlink}
582 @* From ST Microsystems;
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
584
585 @end itemize
586
587 @section Other...
588 @itemize @bullet
589
590 @item @b{ep93xx}
591 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
592
593 @item @b{at91rm9200}
594 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
595
596 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
597 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @end itemize
604
605 @node About Jim-Tcl
606 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex tcl
609
610 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
611 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
612 command interpreter.
613
614 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
615 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
616 much of anything about Tcl.
617 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
618
619 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
620 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
621 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
622 OpenOCD mailing list.
623
624 @itemize @bullet
625 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
626 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
627 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
628 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
629 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
630 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
631
632 @item @b{Missing Features}
633 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
634 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
635 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
636 enabled in OpenOCD.
637
638 @item @b{Scripts}
639 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
640 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
641 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
642
643 @item @b{Commands}
644 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
645 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
646 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
647 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
648
649 @item @b{Historical Note}
650 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
651 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
652 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
653 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
654
655 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
656 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
657 @end itemize
658
659 @node Running
660 @chapter Running
661 @cindex command line options
662 @cindex logfile
663 @cindex directory search
664
665 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
666 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
667 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
668 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
669 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
670 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
671 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
672
673 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
674 tell it how each debug session should work.
675 The @option{--help} option shows:
676 @verbatim
677 bash$ openocd --help
678
679 --help | -h display this help
680 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
681 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
682 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
683 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
684 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
685 --command | -c run <command>
686 @end verbatim
687
688 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
689 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
690 To specify one or more different
691 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
692
693 @example
694 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
695 @end example
696
697 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
698 @enumerate
699 @item the current directory,
700 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
701 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
702 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2407 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2408
2409 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2410 recommended as its replacement.
2411
2412 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2413 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2416 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2417 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2418 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2419 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2423 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2424 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2425 is connected to the host.
2426 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2427 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2428 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2432 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2433 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2434 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2435 @itemize @minus
2436 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2437 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2438 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2439 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2440 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2441 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2442 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2443 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2444 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2445 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2446 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2447 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2448 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2449 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2450 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2451 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2453 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2454 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2455 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2456 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2457 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2458 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2459 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2460 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2461 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2462 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2463 @end itemize
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2467 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2468 default values are used.
2469 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2470 @example
2471 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2472 @end example
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2476 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2477 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2478 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2479 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2480 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2481 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2485 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2486 The default value is 1.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 For example, the interface config file for a
2490 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2491
2492 @example
2493 interface ft2232
2494 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2495 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2496 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2501 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2502 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2503 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2504 interface driver.
2505
2506 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2507 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2508 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2509
2510 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2511 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2512 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2513
2514 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2515 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2516 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2517 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2518 will be used for their customary purpose.
2519
2520 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2521 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2522 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2523 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2524
2525 @itemize @minus
2526 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2527 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2528 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2529 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2530 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2531 switching data and direction as necessary
2532 @end itemize
2533
2534 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2535 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2538 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2539 default values are used.
2540 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2541 @example
2542 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2543 @end example
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2547 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2548 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2549 during device selection.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2553 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2554 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2555 is connected to the host.
2556 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2557 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2558 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2562 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2563 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2564 @end deffn
2565
2566 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2567 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2568 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2569 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2570 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2571 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2572 and initially asserted reset signals.
2573 @end deffn
2574
2575 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2576 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2577 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2578 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2579 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2580 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2581 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2582 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2583 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2584
2585 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2586 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2587 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2588 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2589 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2590 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2591
2592 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2593 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2594 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2595 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2596 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2597 are always driven by the FTDI.
2598
2599 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2600 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2601 @var{name}.
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2605 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item @option{0}, drive low
2608 @item @option{1}, drive high
2609 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2610 @end itemize
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2614 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2618 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2619 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2620 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2621
2622 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2623 processors which are being simulated.
2624
2625 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2626 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2627 sockets instead of TCP.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2631 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2632 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2636 something like:
2637
2638 @example
2639 interface remote_bitbang
2640 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2641 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2642 @end example
2643
2644 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2645 named mysocket:
2646
2647 @example
2648 interface remote_bitbang
2649 remote_bitbang_port 0
2650 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2651 @end example
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2655 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2656 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2657 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2660 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2661 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2662 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2663 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2667 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2668 default values are used.
2669 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2670 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2671 @example
2672 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2673 @end example
2674 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2675 @example
2676 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2677 @end example
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2681 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2682 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2683 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2684 target board.
2685
2686 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2687 @example
2688 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2689 reset_config srst_only
2690 @end example
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2694 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2695 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2696 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2697 @end deffn
2698
2699 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2700 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2701 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2707 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2708 This has one driver-specific command:
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2711 Display either the address of the I/O port
2712 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2713 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2714 This is a write-once setting.
2715 @end deffn
2716 @end deffn
2717
2718 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2719 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2720
2721 @quotation Compatibility Note
2722 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2723 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2724 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2725 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2726 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2727 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2728 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2729 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2730 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2731 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2732 @end quotation
2733
2734 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2735 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2736 @end deffn
2737 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2738 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2741 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2742 @end deffn
2743 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2744 Display the J-Link configuration.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2747 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2748 @end deffn
2749 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2750 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2751 @end deffn
2752 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2753 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2754 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2755 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2756 @end deffn
2757 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2758 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2759 @end deffn
2760 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2761 Reset the current configuration.
2762 @end deffn
2763 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2764 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2765 @end deffn
2766 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2767 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2768 @end deffn
2769 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2770 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2771 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2772
2773 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2774 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2775 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2776
2777 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2778 @end deffn
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2782 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2783 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2784 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2785 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2786
2787 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2788 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2789 This is a write-once setting.
2790 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2791
2792 @itemize @minus
2793 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2794 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2795 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2796 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2797 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2798 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2799 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2800 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2801 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2802 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2803 some versions of
2804 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2805 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2806 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2807 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2808 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2809 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2810 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2811 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2812 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2813 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2814 @end itemize
2815 @end deffn
2816
2817 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2818 Display either the address of the I/O port
2819 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2820 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2821 This is a write-once setting.
2822
2823 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2824 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2825 you may encounter a problem.
2826 @end deffn
2827
2828 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2829 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2830 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2831 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2832 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2833 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2834
2835 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2836 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2837 @quotation Tip
2838 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2839 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2840 @example
2841 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2842 > adapter_khz 500
2843 @end example
2844 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2845 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2846 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2847 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2848 large set of samples.
2849 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2850 @example
2851 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2852 @end example
2853 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2854 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2855
2856 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2857 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2858 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2859 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2860 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2861 @end quotation
2862 @end deffn
2863
2864 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2865 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2866 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2867 @end deffn
2868
2869 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2870 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2871
2872 @example
2873 interface parport
2874 parport_port 0x278
2875 parport_cable wiggler
2876 @end example
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2880 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2881 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2882 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2883 @end deffn
2884 @end deffn
2885
2886 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2887 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2888 @end deffn
2889
2890 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2891 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2895 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2896
2897 @quotation Note
2898 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2899 which are not currently documented here.
2900 @end quotation
2901 @end deffn
2902
2903 @anchor{hla_interface}
2904 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2905 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2906 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2907 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2908
2909 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2910 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2911 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2912 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2913 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2914
2915 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2916 Currently Not Supported.
2917 @end deffn
2918
2919 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2920 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2921 @end deffn
2922
2923 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2924 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2925 @end deffn
2926
2927 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2928 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2929 @end deffn
2930
2931 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2932 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2933 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2934 @end deffn
2935 @end deffn
2936
2937 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2938 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2939 @end deffn
2940
2941 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2942 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2943 @end deffn
2944
2945 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2946 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2947 @end deffn
2948
2949 @quotation Note
2950 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2951 which are not currently documented here.
2952 @end quotation
2953
2954 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2955 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2956 No arguments: print status.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2960 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2961 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2962
2963 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2964 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2965 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2966 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2967 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2968 configuration on exit.
2969
2970 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2971 pinout.
2972
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @section Transport Configuration
2976 @cindex Transport
2977 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2978 and the debug adapter you are using,
2979 several transports may be available to
2980 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2981 @deffn Command {transport list}
2982 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2983 version of OpenOCD.
2984 @end deffn
2985
2986 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2987 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2988
2989 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2990 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2991 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2992 adapter's driver).
2993
2994 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2995 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2996 supported by the debug adapter.
2997
2998 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2999 transport, if any.
3000 @end deffn
3001
3002 @subsection JTAG Transport
3003 @cindex JTAG
3004 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3005 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3006 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3007 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3008 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3009 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3010
3011 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3012 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3013 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3014 hla_jtag}.
3015
3016 @subsection SWD Transport
3017 @cindex SWD
3018 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3019 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3020 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3021 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3022 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3023 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3024 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3025
3026 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3027 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3028 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3029 hla_swd}.
3030
3031 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3032 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3033 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3034 expected to change.
3035 @end deffn
3036 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3037 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3038 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3039 No parameters: displays current settings.
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @subsection SPI Transport
3043 @cindex SPI
3044 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3045 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3046 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3047 solution for flash programming.
3048
3049 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3050 @section JTAG Speed
3051 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3052 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3053 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3054 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3055 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3056 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3057 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3058 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3059 power management software that may be active.
3060
3061 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3062 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3063 target event handler.
3064 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3065 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3066 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3067 sets up those clocks).
3068 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3069 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3070 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3071 in the target config file.
3072 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3073 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3074 config file instead.
3075 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3076 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3077 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3078
3079 @example
3080 jtag_rclk 3000
3081 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3082 @end example
3083
3084 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3085 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3086 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3087 may not be the fastest solution.
3088
3089 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3090 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3091 which support adaptive clocking.
3092
3093 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3094 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3095 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3096 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3097 than the speed specified.
3098
3099 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3100 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3101 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3102 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3103
3104 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3105 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3106 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3107 JTAG clocking after setup.
3108 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3109 If the interface device can not
3110 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3114 @cindex adaptive clocking
3115 @cindex RTCK
3116 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3117 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3118 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3119 @example
3120 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3121 jtag_rclk 3000
3122 @end example
3123 @end defun
3124
3125 @node Reset Configuration
3126 @chapter Reset Configuration
3127 @cindex Reset Configuration
3128
3129 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3130 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3131 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3132 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3133 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3134 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3135 Please see the various board files for examples.
3136
3137 @quotation Note
3138 To maintainers and integrators:
3139 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3140 Normally the board configuration file
3141 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3142 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3143
3144 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3145 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3146 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3147 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3148 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3149 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3150 @end quotation
3151
3152 @section Types of Reset
3153
3154 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3155 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3156 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3157
3158 @itemize @bullet
3159 @item
3160 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3161 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3162 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3163 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3164 @item
3165 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3166 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3167 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3168 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3169 @item
3170 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3171 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3172 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3173 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3174 @item
3175 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3176 several other types of reset.
3177 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3178 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3179 There may be individual module resets.
3180 @end itemize
3181
3182 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3183 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3184 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3185 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3186 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3187 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3188 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3189 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3190 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3191
3192 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3193 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3194
3195 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3196 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3197 common issues are:
3198
3199 @itemize @bullet
3200
3201 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3202 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3203 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3204 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3205 when either of those signals is not connected.
3206 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3207 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3208 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3209 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3210
3211 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3212 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3213 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3214 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3215
3216 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3217 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3218 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3219 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3220 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3221 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3222 hardware debouncing.
3223 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3224 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3225
3226 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3227 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3228 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3229 to use push/pull output drivers.
3230 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3231 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3232 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3233 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3234
3235 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3236 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3237 issues (not limited to errata).
3238 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3239 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3240 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3241 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3242 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3243 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3244 @end itemize
3245
3246 There can also be other issues.
3247 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3248 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3249 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3250 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3251 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3252 Agreement (NDA).
3253
3254 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3255 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3256 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3257
3258 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3259 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3260
3261 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3262
3263 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3264 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3265 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3266 allowing it to be deasserted.
3267 @end deffn
3268
3269 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3270 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3271 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3272 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3273 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3274 @end deffn
3275
3276 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3277 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3278 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3279 allowing it to be deasserted.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3283 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3284 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3288 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3289 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3290 configuration scripts.
3291
3292 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3293 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3294 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3295 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3296 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3297 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3298 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3299 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3300
3301 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3302 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3303 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3304 -- may be specified at a time.
3305 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3306 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3307 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3308 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3309 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3310
3311 @itemize
3312 @item
3313 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3314 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3315 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3316 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3317 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3318
3319 @quotation Tip
3320 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3321 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3322 @end quotation
3323
3324 @item
3325 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3326 signal implementations.
3327 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3328 indicating everything behaves normally.
3329 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3330 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3331 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3332 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3333 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3334 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3335 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3336
3337 @item
3338 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3339 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3340 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3341 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3342 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3343 while SRST is asserted.
3344 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3345 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3346
3347 @item
3348 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3349 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3350 is required to use this option.
3351 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3352 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3353 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3354 be asserted before any target connection.
3355 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3356 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3357 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3358 @end itemize
3359
3360 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3361 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3362 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3363 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3364 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3365
3366 @itemize
3367 @item
3368 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3369 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3370 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3371 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3372
3373 @item
3374 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3375 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3376 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3377 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3378 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3379 @end itemize
3380 @end deffn
3381
3382 @section Custom Reset Handling
3383 @cindex events
3384
3385 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3386 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3387 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3388 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3389 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3390 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3391
3392 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3393 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3394 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3395 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3396 want to reset everything at once.
3397
3398 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3399 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3400 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3401 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3402 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3403 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3404 needs special attention.
3405
3406 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3407 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3408 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3409 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3410 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3411 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3412 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3413 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3414
3415 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3416 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3417 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3418 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3419 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3420
3421 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3422 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3423 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3424 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3425 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3426 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3427 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3428 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3429 or potentially some other value.
3430
3431 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3432 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3433 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3434 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3435 (or their associated targets)
3436 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3437
3438 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3439 they return.
3440 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3441 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3442 @end deffn
3443
3444 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3445 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3446 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3447 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3448 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3449 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3450 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3451 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3452 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3453 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3454 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3455 @end deffn
3456
3457 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3458 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3459 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3460 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3461 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3462 @end deffn
3463
3464
3465 @node TAP Declaration
3466 @chapter TAP Declaration
3467 @cindex TAP declaration
3468 @cindex TAP configuration
3469
3470 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3471 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3472
3473 @itemize @bullet
3474 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3475 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3476 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3477 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3478 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3479 start running that code.
3480 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3481 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3482 and missing connections.
3483 @end itemize
3484
3485 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3486 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3487 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3488 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3489 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3490
3491 @section Scan Chains
3492 @cindex scan chain
3493
3494 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3495 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3496 They also need to be added to
3497 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3498 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3499 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3500 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3501 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3502 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3503 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3504 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3505
3506 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3507 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3508 command, presented in the next chapter.
3509 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3510 debugging targets.)
3511 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3512
3513 @verbatim
3514 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3515 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3516 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3517 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3518 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3519 @end verbatim
3520
3521 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3522 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3523 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3524 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3525 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3526 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3527 until they are told to do so.
3528
3529 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3530 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3531 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3532 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3533
3534 @example
3535 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3536 @end example
3537
3538 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3539 by a given chip.
3540 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3541 and so forth.
3542 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3543 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3544 both inside a single chip and between them.
3545 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3546
3547 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3548 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3549 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3550 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3551 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3552 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3553 includes commands something like this:
3554
3555 @example
3556 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3557 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3558 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3559 @end example
3560
3561 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3562 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3563 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3564
3565 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3566 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3567 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3568 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3569 @example
3570 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3571 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3572 @}
3573 @end example
3574 @end deffn
3575
3576 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3577 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3578 and their status.
3579 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3580 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3581 but systems with a JTAG router can
3582 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3583 @end deffn
3584
3585 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3586 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3587
3588 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3589 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3590
3591 @section TAP Names
3592 @cindex dotted name
3593
3594 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3595 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3596 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3597 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3598 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3599 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3600 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3601 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3602
3603 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3604 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3605 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3606
3607 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3608
3609 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3610 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3611 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3612 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3613
3614 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3615 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3616 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3617 overridable.
3618
3619 @cindex TAP naming convention
3620 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3621 and should follow this convention:
3622
3623 @itemize @bullet
3624 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3625 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3626 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3627 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3628 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3629 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3630 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3631 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3632 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3633 with a single TAP;
3634 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3635 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3636 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3637 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3638 @end itemize
3639
3640 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3641
3642 @itemize @bullet
3643 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3644 @*The length in bits of the
3645 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3646 @end itemize
3647
3648 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3649
3650 @itemize @bullet
3651 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3652 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3653 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3654 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3655 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3656 (the TAP is linked in).
3657 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3658 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3659 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3660 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3661 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3662 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3663 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3664 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3665 values that were found but not included in the list.
3666
3667 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3668 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3669 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3670 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3671 hardware to find these values.
3672 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3673 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3674 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3675 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3676 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3677 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3678 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3679 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3680 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3681 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3682 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3683 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3684 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3685 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3686 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3687 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3688 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3689 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3690 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3691 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3692 @end itemize
3693 @end deffn
3694
3695 @section Other TAP commands
3696
3697 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3698 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3699 At this writing this TAP attribute
3700 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3701 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3702 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3703 See the next section for information about the available events.
3704
3705 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3706 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3707 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3708 @end deffn
3709
3710 @section TAP Events
3711 @cindex events
3712 @cindex TAP events
3713
3714 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3715 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3716 The other applies to debugger targets,
3717 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3718
3719 The TAP events currently defined are:
3720
3721 @itemize @bullet
3722 @item @b{post-reset}
3723 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3724 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3725 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3726 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3727 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3728
3729 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3730 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3731 of any particular target.
3732 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3733 @item @b{setup}
3734 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3735 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3736 @item @b{tap-disable}
3737 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3738 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3739 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3740 @item @b{tap-enable}
3741 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3742 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3743 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3744 @end itemize
3745
3746 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3747 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3748 contents to be accurate), you might:
3749
3750 @example
3751 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3752 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3753 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3754 @}
3755 @end example
3756
3757
3758 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3759 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3760 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3761 @cindex jrc
3762
3763 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3764 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3765 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3766 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3767 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3768
3769 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3770 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3771 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3772 be visible.
3773 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3774 ignores, such as:
3775
3776 @itemize
3777 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3778 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3779 TAPs receive new instructions.
3780 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3781 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3782 @end itemize
3783
3784 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3785 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3786 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3787 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3788
3789 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3790 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3791
3792 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3793 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3794 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3795 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3796 should define TAP event handlers using
3797 code that looks something like this:
3798
3799 @example
3800 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3801 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3802 @}
3803 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3804 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3805 @}
3806 @end example
3807
3808 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3809
3810 @example
3811 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3812 @end example
3813
3814 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3815 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3816 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3817 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3818
3819 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3820 If necessary, disables the tap
3821 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3822 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3823 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3824 and "0" if it is disabled.
3825 @end deffn
3826
3827 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3828 If necessary, enables the tap
3829 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3830 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3831 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3832 and "0" if it is disabled.
3833 @end deffn
3834
3835 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3836 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3837 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3838 and "0" if it is disabled.
3839
3840 @quotation Note
3841 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3842 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3843 @end quotation
3844 @end deffn
3845
3846 @anchor{autoprobing}
3847 @section Autoprobing
3848 @cindex autoprobe
3849 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3850
3851 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3852 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3853 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3854 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3855
3856 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3857 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3858 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3859 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3860 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3861 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3862 right when they come out of reset).
3863
3864 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3865
3866 @example
3867 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3868 reset_config trst_and_srst
3869 jtag_rclk 8
3870 @end example
3871
3872 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3873 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3874
3875 @enumerate
3876 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3877 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3878 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3879 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3880 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3881 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3882 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3883 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3884 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3885 that is discovered.
3886 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3887 register, it will report it.
3888 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3889 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3890 @end enumerate
3891
3892 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3893 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3894 that's a bit more complex:
3895
3896 @example
3897 clock speed 8 kHz
3898 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3899 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3900 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3901 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3902 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3903 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3904 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3905 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3906 @end example
3907
3908 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3909 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3910 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3911 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3912 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3913 and so forth.
3914
3915 @node CPU Configuration
3916 @chapter CPU Configuration
3917 @cindex GDB target
3918
3919 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3920 You can also access these targets without GDB
3921 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3922 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3923 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3924 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3925
3926 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3927 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3928
3929 @section Target List
3930 @cindex target, current
3931 @cindex target, list
3932
3933 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3934 where each member has a name.
3935 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3936 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3937 (plural!) command.
3938 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3939 look like with more than one:
3940 @verbatim
3941 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3942 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3943 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3944 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3945 @end verbatim
3946
3947 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3948 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3949 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3950 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3951 space seen by that current target.
3952 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3953 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3954 are examples; and there are many more.
3955
3956 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3957
3958 @deffn Command {target current}
3959 Returns the name of the current target.
3960 @end deffn
3961
3962 @deffn Command {target names}
3963 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3964 @example
3965 foreach t [target names] @{
3966 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3967 @}
3968 @end example
3969 @end deffn
3970
3971 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3972 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3973
3974 @deffn Command targets [name]
3975 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3976 command names are singular.}
3977
3978 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3979 targets in a user friendly form.
3980
3981 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3982 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3983 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3984 @end deffn
3985
3986 @section Target CPU Types
3987 @cindex target type
3988 @cindex CPU type
3989
3990 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3991 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3992 when calling @command{target create}.
3993 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3994 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3995 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3996 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3997 what core-specific commands may be available
3998 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3999 and more.
4000
4001 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4002 since there's a command to list them.
4003
4004 @anchor{targettypes}
4005 @deffn Command {target types}
4006 Lists all supported target types.
4007 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4008
4009 @itemize @bullet
4010 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4011 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4012 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4013 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4014 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4015 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4016 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4017 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4018 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4019 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4020 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4021 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4022 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4023 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4024 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4025 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4026 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4027 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4028 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4029 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4030 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4031 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4032 @itemize @minus
4033 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4034 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4035 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4036 @end itemize
4037 And two debug interfaces cores:
4038 @itemize @minus
4039 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4040 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4041 @end itemize
4042 @end itemize
4043 @end deffn
4044
4045 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4046 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4047 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4048 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4049 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4050 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4051 reflect design generations;
4052 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4053 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4054
4055 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4056 @section Target Configuration
4057
4058 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4059 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4060 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4061 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4062 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4063
4064 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4065 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4066 optional parts.
4067 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4068 command, created as part of target creation.
4069
4070 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4071 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4072 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4073 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4074 to be much more board-specific.
4075 The key steps you use might look something like this
4076
4077 @example
4078 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4079 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4080 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4081 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4082 @end example
4083
4084 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4085 on-chip SRAM.
4086 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4087 writes to target memory;
4088 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4089 GDB memory checksumming;
4090 and more.
4091
4092 @quotation Warning
4093 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4094 inaccessible when application code
4095 (such as an operating system)
4096 enables or disables the MMU.
4097 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4098 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4099 easy access to other addresses needed.
4100 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4101 @end quotation
4102
4103 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4104 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4105 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4106 controllers.
4107 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4108 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4109 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4110
4111 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4112 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4113 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4114 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4115 purposes including additional configuration.
4116
4117 @itemize @bullet
4118 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4119 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4120 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4121 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4122
4123 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4124 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4125 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4126 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4127 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4128 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4129 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4130
4131 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4132 @end itemize
4133 @end deffn
4134
4135 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4136 The options accepted by this command may also be
4137 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4138 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4139 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4140
4141 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4142 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4143 and changing its endianness.
4144
4145 @itemize @bullet
4146
4147 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4148 used to access this target.
4149
4150 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4151 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4152
4153 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4154 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4155 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4156 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4157 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4158 same event name assigns only one handler.
4159
4160 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4161 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4162 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4163 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4164 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4165 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4166 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4167
4168 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4169 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4170 or virtual address is being used.
4171
4172 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4173 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4174
4175 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4176 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4177 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4178 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4179 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4180
4181 @anchor{rtostype}
4182 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4183 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4184 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4185 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4186
4187 @end itemize
4188 @end deffn
4189
4190 @section Other $target_name Commands
4191 @cindex object command
4192
4193 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4194 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4195
4196 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4197 Once a button is created a button
4198 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4199 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4200 configure it like this:
4201
4202 @example
4203 # Create
4204 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4205 # Modify
4206 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4207 # Query
4208 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4209 # Report
4210 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4211 @end example
4212
4213 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4214 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4215
4216 @example
4217 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4218 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4219 @end example
4220
4221 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4222
4223 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4224 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4225 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4226 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4227 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4228 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4229 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4230 They are not otherwise documented here.
4231 @end deffn
4232
4233 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4234 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4235 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4236 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4237 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4238 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4239 the target side uses raw memory.
4240
4241 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4242 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4243 The script orientation comes from working with data
4244 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4245 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4246 and neither store nor return those values.
4247
4248 @itemize
4249 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4250 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4251 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4252 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4253 @end itemize
4254 @end deffn
4255
4256 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4257 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4258 @command{$target_name configure}
4259 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4260 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4261 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4262 There are a few special cases:
4263
4264 @itemize @bullet
4265 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4266 event named @var{event_name}.
4267 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4268 two parameters.
4269 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4270 This is a special case because this is set using
4271 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4272 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4273 @end itemize
4274
4275 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4276 all the targets you might use something like this:
4277
4278 @example
4279 foreach name [target names] @{
4280 set y [$name cget -endian]
4281 set z [$name cget -type]
4282 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4283 $x $name $y $z]
4284 @}
4285 @end example
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4289 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4290 Displays the current target state:
4291 @code{debug-running},
4292 @code{halted},
4293 @code{reset},
4294 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4295 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4296 @end deffn
4297
4298 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4299 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4300 currently associated with this target.
4301 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4305 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4306 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4307 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4308 @end deffn
4309
4310 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4311 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4312 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4313 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4314 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4315 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4316 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4317 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4318 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4319 @end deffn
4320
4321 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4322 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4323 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4324 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4325 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4326 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4327 @end deffn
4328
4329 @anchor{targetevents}
4330 @section Target Events
4331 @cindex target events
4332 @cindex events
4333 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4334 For example:
4335 @itemize @bullet
4336 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4337 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4338 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4339 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4340 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4341 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4342 to set up system clocks or
4343 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4344 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4345 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4346 @end itemize
4347
4348 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4349 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4350 @command{target create ... -event}.
4351
4352 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4353 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4354 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4355
4356 @example
4357 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4358 echo "Reset..."
4359 reset halt
4360 @}
4361 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4362 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4363 echo "Reset..."
4364 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4365 # we need a reset init.
4366 reset init
4367 @}
4368 @end example
4369
4370 The following target events are defined:
4371
4372 @itemize @bullet
4373 @item @b{debug-halted}
4374 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4375 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4376 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4377 @item @b{early-halted}
4378 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4379 @item @b{examine-start}
4380 @* Before target examine is called.
4381 @item @b{examine-end}
4382 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4383 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4384 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4385 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4386 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4387 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4388 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4389 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4390 @* When GDB disconnects
4391 @item @b{gdb-end}
4392 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4393 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4394 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4395 @code{reset init})
4396 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4397 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4398 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4399 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4400 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4401 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4402 @item @b{gdb-start}
4403 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4404 @item @b{halted}
4405 @* The target has halted
4406 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4407 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4408 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4409 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4410 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4411 @item @b{reset-assert}
4412 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4413 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4414 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4415 it instead of asserting SRST.
4416 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4417 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4418 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4419 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4420 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4421 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4422 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4423 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4424 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4425 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4426 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4427 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4428 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4429 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4430 released on the scan chain.
4431 @item @b{reset-end}
4432 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4433 @ignore
4434 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4435 @* Currently not used
4436 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4437 @* Currently not used
4438 @end ignore
4439 @item @b{reset-init}
4440 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4441 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4442
4443 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4444 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4445 multiplexing, and so on.
4446 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4447 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4448 @item @b{reset-start}
4449 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4450 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4451
4452 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4453 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4454 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4455 @ignore
4456 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4457 @* Currently not used
4458 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4459 @* Currently not used
4460 @end ignore
4461 @item @b{resume-start}
4462 @* Before any target is resumed
4463 @item @b{resume-end}
4464 @* After all targets have resumed
4465 @item @b{resumed}
4466 @* Target has resumed
4467 @item @b{trace-config}
4468 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4469 @end itemize
4470
4471 @node Flash Commands
4472 @chapter Flash Commands
4473
4474 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4475 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4476 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4477 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4478 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4479 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4480 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4481 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4482 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4483
4484 Flash Steps:
4485 @enumerate
4486 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4487 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4488 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4489 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4490 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4491 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4492 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4493 @item GDB Flashing
4494 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4495 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4496 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4497 @end enumerate
4498
4499 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4500 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4501 so that it can't boot.
4502 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4503 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4504
4505 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4506 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4507 @cindex flash configuration
4508
4509 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4510 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4511 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4512 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4513 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4514 see the driver-specific documentation.
4515
4516 @itemize @bullet
4517 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4518 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4519 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4520 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4521 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4522 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4523 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4524 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4525 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4526 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4527 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4528 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4529 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4530 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4531 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4532 commands to the flash controller.
4533 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4534 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4535 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4536 for more information.
4537 @end itemize
4538 @quotation Note
4539 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4540 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4541 @end quotation
4542 @end deffn
4543
4544 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4545 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4546 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4547 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4548 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4549 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4550 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4551 @end deffn
4552
4553 @deffn Command {flash list}
4554 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4555 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4556 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4557 @end deffn
4558
4559 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4560 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4561 depends on the flash type.
4562 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4563 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4564 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4565 but most don't bother.
4566 @end deffn
4567
4568 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4569 @cindex flash erasing
4570 @cindex flash reading
4571 @cindex flash writing
4572 @cindex flash programming
4573 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4574
4575 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4576 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4577 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4578 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4579 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4580
4581 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4582 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4583 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4584 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4585 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4586
4587 @quotation Note
4588 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4589 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4590 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4591 back to a flash bank.
4592 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4593 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4594 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4595 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4596 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4597 @end quotation
4598
4599 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4600 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4601 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4602 disabled first.
4603 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4604 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4605 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4606
4607 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4608 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4609 up to and including @var{last}.
4610 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4611 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4612 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4613 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4614 @end deffn
4615
4616 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4617 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4618 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4619 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4620 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4621 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4622 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4623 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4624 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4625 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4626 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4627 before erase starts.
4628 @end deffn
4629
4630 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4631 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4632 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4633 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4634 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4635 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4636 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4637 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4638 before issuing this command.
4639 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4640 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4641 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4642 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4643 @end deffn
4644 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4645
4646 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4647 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4648 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4649 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4650 @end deffn
4651
4652 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4653 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4654 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4655 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4656 @end deffn
4657
4658 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4659 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4660 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4662 @end deffn
4663
4664 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4665 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4666 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4667 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4668 to the base address for each section in the image.
4669 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4670 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4671 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4672 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4673 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4674 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4675 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4676 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4677 each image section.
4678
4679 @quotation Warning
4680 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4681 data you want to preserve.
4682 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4683 sections might be erased with no notice.
4684 @itemize
4685 @item
4686 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4687 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4688 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4689 @item
4690 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4691 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4692 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4693 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4694 @end itemize
4695 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4696 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4697 @end quotation
4698
4699 @end deffn
4700
4701 @section Other Flash commands
4702 @cindex flash protection
4703
4704 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4705 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4706 and display that status.
4707 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4708 @end deffn
4709
4710 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4711 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4713 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4714 and possibly stale information.
4715 @end deffn
4716
4717 @anchor{flashprotect}
4718 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4719 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4720 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4721 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4722 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4723 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4724 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4725 @end deffn
4726
4727 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4728 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4729 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4730 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4731 @end deffn
4732
4733 @anchor{program}
4734 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4735 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4736 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4737 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4738 @end deffn
4739
4740 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4741 @section Flash Driver List
4742 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4743 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4744 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4745
4746 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4747 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4748 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4749
4750 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4751
4752 @itemize
4753 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4754 @end itemize
4755
4756 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4757 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4758 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4759 @example
4760 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4761 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4762 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4763 @end example
4764 @end deffn
4765
4766 @subsection External Flash
4767
4768 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4769 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4770 @cindex CFI
4771 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4772 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4773 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4774 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4775 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4776 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4777 configure a bus and its timings), or
4778 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4779 on the flash chip.
4780 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4781 speed up operation.
4782
4783 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4784
4785 @itemize
4786 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4787 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4788 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4789 @end itemize
4790
4791 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4792 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4793
4794 @example
4795 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4796 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4797 @end example
4798
4799 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4800 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4801 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4802
4803 @example
4804 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4805 @end example
4806
4807 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4808 @end deffn
4809
4810 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4811 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4812 @cindex SPI
4813 @cindex jtagspi
4814 @cindex bscan_spi
4815 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4816 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4817 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4818 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4819 accessed through JTAG.
4820
4821 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4822 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4823 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4824 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4825 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4826 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4827
4828 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4829 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4830 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4831 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4832 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4833 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4834 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4835 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4836
4837 @itemize
4838 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4839 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4840 @var{USER1} instruction.
4841 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4842 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4843 @end itemize
4844
4845 @example
4846 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4847 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4848 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4849 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4850 @end example
4851 @end deffn
4852
4853 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4854 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4855 @cindex SPIFI
4856 @cindex lpcspifi
4857 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4858 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4859 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4860
4861 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4862 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4863 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4864 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4865 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4866
4867 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4868 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4869 are configured by the driver.
4870
4871 @example
4872 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4873 @end example
4874
4875 @end deffn
4876
4877 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4878 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4879 @cindex SMI
4880 @cindex stmsmi
4881 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4882 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4883 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4884 SPI flash devices.
4885 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4886 flash devices can be connected.
4887
4888 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4889 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4890 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4891 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4892 the flash content.
4893
4894 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4895 to identify the memory bank.
4896 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4897 flash size, are detected automatically.
4898
4899 @example
4900 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4901 @end example
4902
4903 @end deffn
4904
4905 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4906 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4907 Microcontroller platform.
4908
4909 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4910 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4911
4912 @example
4913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4914 @end example
4915
4916 @end deffn
4917
4918 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4919
4920 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4921 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4922 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4923 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4924 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4925 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4926
4927 @example
4928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4929 @end example
4930 @end deffn
4931
4932 @anchor{at91samd}
4933 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4934 @cindex at91samd
4935
4936 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4937 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4938 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4939 processor to be halted.
4940 @end deffn
4941
4942 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4943 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4944 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4945 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4946 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4947 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4948
4949 @example
4950 at91samd set-security enable
4951 @end example
4952 @end deffn
4953
4954 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4955 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4956 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4957 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4958 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4959 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4960 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4961 in order to disable this feature.
4962
4963 @example
4964 at91samd eeprom
4965 at91samd eeprom 1024
4966 @end example
4967 @end deffn
4968
4969 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4970 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4971 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4972 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4973 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4974 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4975
4976 @example
4977 at91samd bootloader
4978 at91samd bootloader 16384
4979 @end example
4980 @end deffn
4981
4982 @end deffn
4983
4984 @anchor{at91sam3}
4985 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4986 @cindex at91sam3
4987 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4988 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4989 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4990 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4991 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4992 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4993 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4994 chips are confirmed.}
4995
4996 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4997 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4998 the following fixed locations:
4999
5000 @example
5001 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5002 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5003 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5004 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5005 @end example
5006
5007 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5008 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5009 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5010
5011 @itemize
5012 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5013 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5014 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5015 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5016 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5017 @end itemize
5018
5019 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5020
5021 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5022 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5023 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5024 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5025 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5026 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5027 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5028
5029 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5030 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5031 @end deffn
5032
5033 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5034 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5035 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5036 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5037 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5038 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5039 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5040 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5041 @end deffn
5042
5043 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5044 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5045 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5046 @end deffn
5047 @end deffn
5048
5049 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5050 @cindex at91sam4
5051 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5052 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5053 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5054 @end deffn
5055
5056 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5057 @cindex at91sam4l
5058 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5059 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5060 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5061
5062 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5063 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5064 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5065 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5066 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5067 @end deffn
5068 @end deffn
5069
5070 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5071 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5072 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5073 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5074 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5075
5076 @example
5077 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5078 @end example
5079
5080 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5081 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5082
5083 @itemize
5084 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5085 @item @var{banks}
5086 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5087 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5088 @item @var{pages_size}
5089 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5090 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5091 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5092 @end itemize
5093
5094 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5095 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5096 will be autoconfigured.
5097 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5098
5099 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5100 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5101 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5102 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5103 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5104
5105 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5106 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5107 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5108 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5109 are not truly general purpose).
5110 @quotation Note
5111 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5112 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5113 @end quotation
5114 @end deffn
5115 @end deffn
5116
5117 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5118 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5119 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5120 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5121 @end deffn
5122
5123 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5124 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5125 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5126 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5127 autoconfigures itself.
5128 @example
5129 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5130 @end example
5131 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5132 supported.}
5133 @end deffn
5134
5135 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5136 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5137 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5138 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5139 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5140 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5141 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5142
5143 @example
5144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5145 @end example
5146 @end deffn
5147
5148 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5149 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5150 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5151 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5152 microcontroller families from NXP.
5153
5154 @quotation Note
5155 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5156 driver:
5157 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5158 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5159 @end quotation
5160
5161 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5162 which must appear in the following order:
5163
5164 @itemize
5165 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5166 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5167 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5168 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5169 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5170 LPC43x[2357])
5171 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5172 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5173 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5174 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5175 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5176 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5177 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5178 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5179 at which the core is running
5180 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5181 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5182 @quotation Note
5183 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5184 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5185 However, if you do provide it,
5186 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5187 @end quotation
5188 @end itemize
5189
5190 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5191
5192 @example
5193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5194 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5195 @end example
5196
5197 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5198 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5199 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5200 @end deffn
5201 @end deffn
5202
5203 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5204 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5205 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5206 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5207 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5208 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5209
5210 @example
5211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5212 @end example
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5216 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5217 from NXP.
5218
5219 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5220 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5221 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5222 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5223 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5224 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5225 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5226 you start the PLL.
5227
5228 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5229
5230 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5231 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5232 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5233
5234 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5235 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5236 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5237 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5238 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5239 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5240 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5241
5242 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5243 @example
5244 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5245 @end example
5246
5247 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5248 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5249 @code{flash banks} command.
5250
5251 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5252 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5253 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5254 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5255 a known signature.
5256 Example:
5257 @example
5258 lpc2900 signature 0
5259 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5260 @end example
5261 @end deffn
5262
5263 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5264 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5265 saves it to a file in binary format.
5266 Example:
5267 @example
5268 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5269 @end example
5270 @end deffn
5271
5272 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5273 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5274 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5275 command:
5276
5277 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5278 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5279 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5280 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5281
5282 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5283 Example:
5284 @example
5285 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5286 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5287 @end example
5288 @end deffn
5289
5290 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5291 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5292 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5293 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5294 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5295 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5296 912 bytes.
5297 @quotation Attention
5298 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5299 @end quotation
5300 Example:
5301 @example
5302 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5303 @end example
5304 @end deffn
5305
5306 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5307 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5308 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5309 after the next power cycle.
5310 @quotation Attention
5311 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5312 @end quotation
5313 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5314 Example:
5315 @example
5316 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5317 flash info 0
5318 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5319 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5320 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5321 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5322 @end example
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5326 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5327 effective after the next power cycle.
5328 @quotation Attention
5329 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5330 @end quotation
5331 Examples:
5332 @example
5333 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5334 @end example
5335 @end deffn
5336 @end deffn
5337
5338 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5339 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5340 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5341 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5342
5343 @example
5344 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5345 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5346 @end example
5347
5348 @itemize @bullet
5349 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5350 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5351 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5352 @end itemize
5353
5354 Example usage:
5355 @example
5356 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5357 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5358 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5359 @} else @{
5360 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5361 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5362 @}
5363 @end example
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5367 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5368 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5369
5370 @example
5371 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5372 @end example
5373
5374 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5375
5376 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5377 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5378 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5379 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5380 code.
5381 @end deffn
5382
5383 @end deffn
5384
5385 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5386 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5387 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5388
5389 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5390 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5391 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5392 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5393
5394 @example
5395 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5396 @end example
5397 @end deffn
5398
5399 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5400 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5401 and integrate flash memory.
5402
5403 @example
5404 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5406 @end example
5407
5408 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5409 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5410 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5411 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5412 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5413 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5414 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5415 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5416 @end deffn
5417 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5418 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5419 This will remove any Code Protection.
5420 @end deffn
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5424 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5425 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5426 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5427 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5428
5429 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5430 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5431
5432 @example
5433 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5434 @end example
5435
5436 psoc4-specific commands
5437 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5438 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5439
5440 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5441 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5442
5443 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5444 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5445 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5446
5447 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5448 @end deffn
5449
5450 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5451 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5452
5453 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5454 @end deffn
5455 @end deffn
5456
5457 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5458 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5459 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5460 and SWD interface.
5461 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5462 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5463
5464 @example
5465 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5466 @end example
5467
5468 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5469
5470 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5471 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5472 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5473 @end deffn
5474
5475 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5476 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5477 @end deffn
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5481 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5482 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5483 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5484 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5485 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5486 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5487 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5488
5489 @example
5490 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5491 @end example
5492
5493 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5494 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5495 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5496 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5497 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5498 disabled.
5499
5500 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5501 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5502 @quotation Warning
5503 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5504 applied to all of them.
5505 @end quotation
5506 @end deffn
5507 @end deffn
5508
5509 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5510 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5511 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5512 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5513 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5514
5515 @example
5516 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5517 @end example
5518
5519 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5520 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5521 the flash driver.
5522
5523 @example
5524 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5525 @end example
5526
5527 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5528 as per the following example.
5529 @example
5530 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5531 @end example
5532
5533 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5534 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5535 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5536 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5537 are defined:
5538
5539 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5540 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5541 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5542 @end deffn
5543
5544 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5545 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5546 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5547 @end deffn
5548
5549 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5550 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5551 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5552 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5553 @end deffn
5554
5555 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5556 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5557 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5558 @end deffn
5559 @end deffn
5560
5561 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5562 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5563 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5564 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5565 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5566
5567 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5568 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5569 the flash driver.
5570
5571 @example
5572 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5573 @end example
5574
5575 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5576
5577 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5578 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5579 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5583 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5584 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5585 @end deffn
5586 @end deffn
5587
5588 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5589 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5590 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5591 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5592 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5593
5594 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5595 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5596 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5597 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5598 second bank.
5599
5600 @example
5601 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5602 @end example
5603
5604 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5605
5606 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5607 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5608 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5609 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5610 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5611 @end deffn
5612 @end deffn
5613
5614 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5615 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5616 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5617 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5618 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5619
5620 @example
5621 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5622 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5623 @end example
5624
5625 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5626 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5627 for the specified flash bank.
5628 @end deffn
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5632 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5633 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5634 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5635 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5636
5637 @example
5638 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5639 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5640 @end example
5641
5642 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5643 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5644 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5645
5646 @itemize @bullet
5647 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5648 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5649 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5650 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5651 @end itemize
5652 @end deffn
5653
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5657 @cindex str9xpec
5658
5659 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5660 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5661 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5662 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5663
5664 Here is some background info to help
5665 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5666 the str9:
5667 @enumerate
5668 @item
5669 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5670 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5671 @item
5672 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5673 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5674 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5675 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5676 @end enumerate
5677
5678 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5679 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5680 configured for flash bank 0.
5681 @example
5682 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5683 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5684 jtag_reset 0 1
5685 # turn off target polling
5686 poll off
5687 # disable str9 core
5688 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5689 # read option bytes
5690 str9xpec options_read 0
5691 # re-enable str9 core
5692 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5693 poll on
5694 reset halt
5695 @end example
5696 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5697 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5698 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5699 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5700
5701 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5702
5703 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5704 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5708 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5709 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5710 @end deffn
5711
5712 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5713 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5714 erase the device.
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5718 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5719 @end deffn
5720
5721 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5722 Configure str9 boot bank.
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5726 Configure str9 lvd source.
5727 @end deffn
5728
5729 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5730 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5731 @end deffn
5732
5733 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5734 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5735 @end deffn
5736
5737 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5738 Read str9 option bytes.
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5742 Write str9 option bytes.
5743 @end deffn
5744
5745 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5746 unlock str9 device.
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @end deffn
5750
5751 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5752 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5753 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5754 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5755
5756 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5757
5758 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5759 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5760 @end deffn
5761
5762 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5763 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5764 @end deffn
5765
5766 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5767 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5768 the flash clock.
5769 @end deffn
5770 @end deffn
5771
5772 @section NAND Flash Commands
5773 @cindex NAND
5774
5775 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5776 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5777 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5778
5779 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5780 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5781 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5782 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5783 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5784 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5785
5786 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5787 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5788 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5789 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5790 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5791 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5792 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5793 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5794 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5795 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5796
5797 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5798 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5799 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5800 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5801 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5802 every 512 bytes of data.
5803
5804 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5805 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5806 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5807 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5808 ECC mode is used.
5809
5810 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5811 @enumerate
5812 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5813 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5814 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5815 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5816 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5817 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5818 to access that device.
5819 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5820 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5821 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5822 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5823 de-brick a board.
5824 @end enumerate
5825
5826 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5827 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5828 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5829 are only 32 bits wide.
5830 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5831 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5832 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5833 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5834
5835 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5836 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
5837 @cindex NAND configuration
5838
5839 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5840 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5841 OpenOCD has initialized.
5842
5843 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5844 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5845 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5846 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5847 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5848 they were a single (larger) device.
5849 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5850 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5851
5852 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5853 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5854 configuration files, not interactively.
5855
5856 @itemize @bullet
5857 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5858 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5859 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5860 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5861 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5862 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5863 commands to the NAND controller.
5864 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5865 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5866 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5867 for more information.
5868 @end itemize
5869 @end deffn
5870
5871 @deffn Command {nand list}
5872 Prints a summary of each device declared
5873 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5874 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5875 @example
5876 > nand list
5877 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5878 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5879 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5880 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5881 >
5882 @end example
5883 @end deffn
5884
5885 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5886 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5887 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5888 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5889 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5890 it with most other NAND commands.
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5894
5895 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5896 @cindex NAND reading
5897 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5898 starting at the specified offset.
5899 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5900
5901 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5902 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5903
5904 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5905 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5906 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5907
5908 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5909 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5910 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5911 method which handled that error correction.
5912
5913 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5914 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5915 @itemize @bullet
5916 @item no oob_* parameter
5917 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5918 @item @code{oob_raw}
5919 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5920 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5921 spare areas associated with each data page.
5922 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5923 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5924 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5925 @item @code{oob_only}
5926 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5927 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5928 spare areas associated with each data page.
5929 @end itemize
5930 @end deffn
5931
5932 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5933 @cindex NAND erasing
5934 @cindex NAND programming
5935 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5936 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5937 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5938 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5939 If those parameters are not specified,
5940 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5941 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5942
5943 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5944 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5945 block marker.
5946 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5947 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5948 @end deffn
5949
5950 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5951 @cindex NAND writing
5952 @cindex NAND programming
5953 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5954 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5955 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5956 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5957
5958 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5959 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5960
5961 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5962 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5963 past the end of the device.
5964 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5965 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5966 if that's being written.)
5967
5968 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5969 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5970 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5971
5972 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5973 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
5974 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
5975 @itemize @bullet
5976 @item no oob_* parameter
5977 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5978 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
5979 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5980 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
5981 with hardware-computed ECC data.
5982 @item @code{oob_only}
5983 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
5984 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
5985 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
5986 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
5987 @item @code{oob_raw}
5988 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
5989 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
5990 un-altered OOB.
5991 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5992 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
5993 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
5994 @item @code{oob_softecc}
5995 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5996 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
5997 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
5998 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5999 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6000 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6001 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6002 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6003 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6004 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6005 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6006 @end itemize
6007 @end deffn
6008
6009 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6010 @cindex NAND verification
6011 @cindex NAND programming
6012 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6013 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6014 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6015
6016 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6017 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6018
6019 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6020 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6021 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6022 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6023 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6024
6025 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6026 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6027 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6028
6029 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6030 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6031 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6032 be removed in a future release.
6033 @end deffn
6034
6035 @subsection Other NAND commands
6036 @cindex NAND other commands
6037
6038 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6039 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6040 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6041 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6042 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6043 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6044 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6045 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6046
6047 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6048 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6049 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6050 @end deffn
6051
6052 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6053 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6054 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6055 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6056 status for each block.
6057 @end deffn
6058
6059 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6060 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6061 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6062
6063 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6064 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6065 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6066 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6067 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6068
6069 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6070 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6071 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6072 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6073 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6074 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6075 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6076 @end deffn
6077
6078 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6079 @subsection NAND Driver List
6080 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6081 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6082 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6083
6084 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6085 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6086 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6087 address of the ECC controller.
6088 @example
6089 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6090 @end example
6091 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6092 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6093 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6094 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6095 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6096 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6097 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6098 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6099 @end deffn
6100 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6101 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6102 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6103 @end deffn
6104
6105 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6106 properly configured for input or output.
6107 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6108 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6109 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6110 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6111 @end deffn
6112 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6113 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6114 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6115 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6116 @end deffn
6117 @end deffn
6118
6119 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6120 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6121 chips from Texas Instruments.
6122 It takes three extra parameters:
6123 address of the NAND chip;
6124 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6125 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6126 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6127 @example
6128 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6129 @end example
6130 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6131 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6132 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6133 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6134 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6135 @end deffn
6136
6137 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6138 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6139 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6140 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6141 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6142 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6143 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6144 @end deffn
6145
6146 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6147 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6148 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6149 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6150 @end deffn
6151 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6152
6153 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6154 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6155 should work for this chip aswell.
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6159 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6160 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6161 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6162 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6163 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6164 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6165 @example
6166 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6167 @end example
6168 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6169 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6170 without parameter query status.
6171 @end deffn
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6175 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6176 parameter: the address of the controller.
6177 @example
6178 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6179 @end example
6180 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6181 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6182 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6183 change any behavior.
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6187 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6188 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6189 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6190 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6191 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6192 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6193 specialized commands.
6194 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6195 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6196 change any behavior.
6197 @end deffn
6198
6199 @section mFlash
6200
6201 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6202 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6203
6204 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6205 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6206 address @var{base}.
6207 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6208 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6209
6210 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6211
6212 @example
6213 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6214 @end example
6215
6216 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6217
6218 @example
6219 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6220 @end example
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @subsection mFlash commands
6224 @cindex mFlash commands
6225
6226 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6227 Configure mflash PLL.
6228 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6229 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6230 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6231 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6232 @end deffn
6233
6234 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6235 Configure bootable option.
6236 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6237 (4kB) for boot.
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6241 Configure storage information.
6242 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6243 written.
6244 @end deffn
6245
6246 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6247 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6248 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6249 @end deffn
6250
6251 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6252 Probe mflash.
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6256 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6257 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6258 @end deffn
6259
6260 @node Flash Programming
6261 @chapter Flash Programming
6262
6263 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6264 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6265 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6266
6267 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6268 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6269
6270 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6271 @enumerate
6272 @item 'init' is executed.
6273 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6274 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6275 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6276 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6277 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6278 @end enumerate
6279
6280 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6281
6282 @example
6283 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6284 # are optional parameters
6285 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6286 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6287
6288 # binary files need the flash address passing
6289 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6290 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6291 @end example
6292
6293 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6294 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6295 @cindex PLD
6296 @cindex FPGA
6297
6298 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6299 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6300 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6301 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6302 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6303 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6304 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6305
6306 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6307
6308 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6309 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6310 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6311
6312 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6313 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6314
6315 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6316 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6317 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6318 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6319 behavior.
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6323 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6327 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6328 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6332
6333 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6334 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6335 that particular type of PLD.
6336
6337 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6338 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6339 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6340
6341 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6342 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6343 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6344
6345 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6346 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6347 for FPGA @var{num}.
6348 @end deffn
6349 @end deffn
6350
6351 @node General Commands
6352 @chapter General Commands
6353 @cindex commands
6354
6355 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6356 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6357 commands are documented elsewhere.
6358
6359 Intent:
6360 @itemize @bullet
6361 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6362 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6363 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6364 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6365
6366 @item @b{From the human}
6367 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6368 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6369
6370 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6371 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6372 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6373
6374 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6375 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6376 port is 5555.
6377 @end itemize
6378
6379
6380 @section Daemon Commands
6381
6382 @deffn {Command} exit
6383 Exits the current telnet session.
6384 @end deffn
6385
6386 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6387 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6388 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6389 Not every command provides helptext.
6390
6391 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6392 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6393 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6394 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6398 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6399 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6400 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6401 Useful in connection with script files
6402 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6406 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6407 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6408 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @anchor{debuglevel}
6412 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6413 @cindex message level
6414 Display debug level.
6415 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6416 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6417 Level 0 is error messages only;
6418 level 1 adds warnings;
6419 level 2 adds informational messages;
6420 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6421 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6422 the command line along with the location of that log
6423 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6424 @xref{Running}.
6425 @end deffn
6426
6427 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6428 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6429 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6430 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6431 @example
6432 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6433 @end example
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6437 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6438 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6442 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6446 @section Target State handling
6447 @cindex reset
6448 @cindex halt
6449 @cindex target initialization
6450
6451 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6452 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6453 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6454 a current target which is used to perform the
6455 various operations. The current target may be changed
6456 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6457 target which should become current.
6458
6459 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6460 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6461 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6462 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6463 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6464
6465 @emph{With no arguments}:
6466 list all available registers for the current target,
6467 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6468 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6469 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6470 are flagged as such.
6471
6472 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6473 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6474 bypassing any internal cache.
6475
6476 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6477 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6478 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6479 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6480 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6481 relevant module will flush such values.
6482
6483 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6484 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6485
6486 @example
6487 > reg
6488 ===== ARM registers
6489 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6490 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6491 (2) r2 (/32)
6492 ...
6493 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6494 >
6495 @end example
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6499 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6500 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6501 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6502 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6503 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6504 (and enter debug mode).
6505 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6506
6507 @quotation Warning
6508 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6509 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6510 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6511 power mode by gating the core clock;
6512 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6513
6514 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6515 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6516 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6517 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6518 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6519 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6520
6521 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6522 work with a JTAG debugger.
6523 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6524 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6525 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6526 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6527 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6528 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6529 @end quotation
6530
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn Command resume [address]
6534 Resume the target at its current code position,
6535 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6536 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6537 @end deffn
6538
6539 @deffn Command step [address]
6540 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6541 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6542 @end deffn
6543
6544 @anchor{resetcommand}
6545 @deffn Command reset
6546 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6547 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6548 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6549 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6550 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6551 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6552
6553 The optional parameter specifies what should
6554 happen after the reset.
6555 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6556 The other options will not work on all systems.
6557 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6558
6559 @itemize @minus
6560 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6561 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6562 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6563 @end itemize
6564 @end deffn
6565
6566 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6567 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6568 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6569 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6570 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6571 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6572 state.
6573 @end deffn
6574
6575 @section I/O Utilities
6576
6577 These commands are available when
6578 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6579 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6580 notably the ZY1000.
6581 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6582
6583 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6584
6585 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6586 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6587 the text file @file{filename}.
6588 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6589 The last string is followed by a newline.
6590 @end deffn
6591
6592 @deffn Command cat filename
6593 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6594 @end deffn
6595
6596 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6597 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6598 into @file{dest_filename}.
6599 @end deffn
6600
6601 @deffn Command ip
6602 @emph{No description provided.}
6603 @end deffn
6604
6605 @deffn Command ls
6606 @emph{No description provided.}
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @deffn Command mac
6610 @emph{No description provided.}
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn Command meminfo
6614 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6615 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 @deffn Command peek
6619 @emph{No description provided.}
6620 @end deffn
6621
6622 @deffn Command poke
6623 @emph{No description provided.}
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @deffn Command rm filename
6627 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6628 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn Command trunc filename
6632 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6633 @end deffn
6634
6635 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6636 @section Memory access commands
6637 @cindex memory access
6638
6639 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6640 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6641 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6642 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6643
6644 @enumerate
6645 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6646 to change the current target.
6647 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6648 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6649 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6650 @end enumerate
6651
6652 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6653 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6654 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6655 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6656 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6657 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6658 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6659 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6660 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6661 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6662 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6663 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6664 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6665 @end deffn
6666
6667 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6668 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6669 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6670 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6671 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6672 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6673 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6674 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6675 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6676 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6677 @end deffn
6678
6679 @anchor{imageaccess}
6680 @section Image loading commands
6681 @cindex image loading
6682 @cindex image dumping
6683
6684 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6685 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6686 binary file named @var{filename}.
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6690 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6691 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6692 @end deffn
6693
6694 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6695 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6696 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6697 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6698 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6699 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6700 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6701 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6702 separately.
6703 @end deffn
6704
6705 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6706 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6707 The file format may optionally be specified
6708 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6709 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6710 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6711 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6712 @example
6713 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6714 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6715 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6716 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6717 $address $length
6718 @}
6719 @end example
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6723 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6724 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6725 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6726 The file format may optionally be specified
6727 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6728 @end deffn
6729
6730 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6731 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6732 The file format may optionally be specified
6733 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6734 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6735 @end deffn
6736
6737
6738 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6739 @cindex breakpoint
6740 @cindex watchpoint
6741
6742 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6743 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6744 watchpoints.
6745 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6746
6747 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6748 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6749 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6750 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6751 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6752 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6753
6754 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6755 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6759 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6763 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6767 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6768 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6769 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6770 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6771 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6772 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6773 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6774 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @section Misc Commands
6778
6779 @cindex profiling
6780 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6781 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6782 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6783 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6784 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6785 limit the address range.
6786 @end deffn
6787
6788 @deffn Command {version}
6789 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6793 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6794 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6798 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6799 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6800 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6801
6802 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6803 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6804 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6805 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6806
6807 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6808 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6809 @cindex tracing
6810 @cindex ETM
6811 @cindex ETB
6812
6813 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6814 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6815 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6816
6817 @itemize
6818 @item
6819 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6820 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6821 supports such an interface.
6822 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6823 and trace port support.)
6824 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6825 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6826 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6827 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6828 in the board-specific configuration file.
6829 @item
6830 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6831 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6832 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6833 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6834 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6835 @end itemize
6836
6837 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6838
6839 @quotation Issues
6840 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6841 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6842
6843 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6844 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6845 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6846 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6847 dummy trace port driver}.
6848
6849 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6850 as well as tracing only during specific states
6851 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6852
6853 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6854 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6855 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6856 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6857 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6858
6859 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6860 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6861 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6862 this original style of JTAG access.
6863 @end quotation
6864
6865 @subsection ETM Configuration
6866 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6867
6868 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6869 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6870 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6871
6872 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6873 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6874 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6875 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6876 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6877 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6878 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6879 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6880 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6881
6882 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6883 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6884 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6885
6886 @quotation Warning
6887 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6888 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6889 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6890 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6891 @end quotation
6892
6893 @quotation Note
6894 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6895 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6896 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6897 what CPU activities are traced.
6898 @end quotation
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn Command {etm info}
6902 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6903 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6904 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6905 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @deffn Command {etm status}
6909 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6910 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6911 Did trace data overflow?
6912 Was it triggered?
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6916 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6917 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6918 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6919 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6920
6921 @itemize
6922 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6923 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6924 The value is one of
6925 @option{none} (save nothing),
6926 @option{data} (save data),
6927 @option{address} (save addresses),
6928 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6929 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6930 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6931 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6932 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6933 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6934 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6935 trace stream without an image of the code.
6936 @end itemize
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6940 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6941 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6942 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6943 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6944
6945 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6946 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6947 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6951
6952 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6953 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6954 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6955
6956 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6957 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6958 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6959 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6960 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6961 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6962 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6963
6964 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6965
6966 @itemize
6967 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6968 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6969 for instruction access within that function's body.
6970 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6971 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6972 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6973 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6974 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6975 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6976 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6977 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6978 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6979 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6980 @item @emph{... more}
6981 @end itemize
6982
6983 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6984 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6985
6986 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6987 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6988 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6992 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6993 @end deffn
6994
6995 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6996 Opens an image file.
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7000 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7001 @end deffn
7002
7003 @deffn Command {etm start}
7004 Starts trace data collection.
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7008 Stops trace data collection.
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7012 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7013
7014 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7015
7016 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7017 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7018 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7019 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7020 any trace data collection.}
7021 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7022 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7023 @end deffn
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7027 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7028 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7029 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7030 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7031 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7032 @end deffn
7033 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7034 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7035 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7036 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7037 trace trigger becomes active.
7038
7039 @itemize
7040 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7041 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7042 afterwards.
7043 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7044 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7045 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7046 what caused that event to happen.
7047 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7048 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7049 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7050 how the event caused trouble.
7051 @end itemize
7052 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7053 @end deffn
7054
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7058 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7059 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7060 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7061 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7062
7063 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7064 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7065
7066 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7067 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7068 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7072 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7076 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7077 @end deffn
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080
7081 @section Generic ARM
7082 @cindex ARM
7083
7084 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7085 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7086 commands that may be available.
7087
7088 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7089 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7090 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7091 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7092 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7093 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7094 @end deffn
7095
7096 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7097 @cindex disassemble
7098 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7099 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7100 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7101 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7102 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7103 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7104 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7105
7106 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7107 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7108 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7109 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7110 with a handful of exceptions.
7111 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7115 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7116 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7117 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7118 and using the MCR instruction.
7119 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7120 an ARM register.)
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7124 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7125 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7126 and the MRC instruction.
7127 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7128 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7129 an ARM register.)
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7133 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7134 core mode if necessary.
7135 @end deffn
7136
7137 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7138 @cindex ARM semihosting
7139 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7140
7141 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7142 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7143 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7144 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7145 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7146 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7147 @end deffn
7148
7149 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7150 @cindex ARMv4
7151 @cindex ARMv5
7152
7153 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7154 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7155 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7156 variant.
7157
7158 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7159 @cindex ARM7
7160 @cindex ARM9
7161
7162 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7163 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7164 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7165 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7166
7167 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7168 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7169 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7170 instead of breakpoints.
7171 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7172
7173 This should be
7174 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7175 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7176 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7177 @end deffn
7178
7179 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7180 @cindex DCC
7181 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7182 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7183 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7184
7185 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7186 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7187 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7191 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7192 that don't check completion of the operation.
7193 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7194
7195 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7196 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7197 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7201 @cindex ARM720T
7202
7203 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7204 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7205 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7206 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7207
7208 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7209 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7210 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7211
7212 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7213 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7214 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7215 @end deffn
7216
7217 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7218 @cindex ARM9
7219
7220 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7221 integer processors.
7222 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7223
7224 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7225 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7226 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7227 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7228
7229 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7230 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7231 @cindex vector_catch
7232 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7233 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7234 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7235 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7236 to those hardware vectors.
7237
7238 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7239 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7240 vector catch hardware to intercept
7241 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7242 @option{none} of them,
7243 or a list with one or more of the following:
7244 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7245 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7249 @cindex ARM920T
7250
7251 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7252 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7253 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7254 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7255 and ARM9 commands.
7256
7257 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7258 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7259 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7260 @end deffn
7261
7262 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7263 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7264 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7265 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7266 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7267 (Not all registers can be written.)
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7271 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7272 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7273
7274 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7275 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7276 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7277 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7278 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7279 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7283 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7287 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7288 @end deffn
7289
7290 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7291 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7292
7293 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7294 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7295 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7296 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7297 and ARM9 commands.
7298
7299 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7300 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7301
7302 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7303 Print information about the caches found.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7307 @cindex ARM966E
7308
7309 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7310 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7311 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7312 and ARM9 commands.
7313
7314 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7315 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7316 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7317 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7318 ARM966E-S TRM.
7319 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7320 as required for BIST support.
7321 @end deffn
7322
7323 @subsection XScale specific commands
7324 @cindex XScale
7325
7326 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7327
7328 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7329 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7330 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7331 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7332 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7333 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7334 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7335
7336 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7337 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7338 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7339 the mini-IC.
7340
7341 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7342 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7343 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7344 code layout in memory:
7345 @example
7346 _vectors:
7347 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7348 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7349 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7350 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7351 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7352 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7353 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7354 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7355 .org 0x100
7356 .long real_reset_vector
7357 .long real_ui_handler
7358 .long real_swi_handler
7359 .long real_pf_abort
7360 .long real_data_abort
7361 .long 0 /* unused */
7362 .long real_irq_handler
7363 .long real_fiq_handler
7364 @end example
7365
7366 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7367 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7368 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7369 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7370 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7371 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7372 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7373 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7374 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7375 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7376 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7377 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7378 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7379 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7380 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7381 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7382 software.
7383
7384 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7385 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7386 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7387 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7388
7389 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7390 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7391 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7392 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7393 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7394 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7395 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7396 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7397 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7398
7399 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7400 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7401
7402 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7403 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7404 @end deffn
7405
7406 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7407 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7411 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7415 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7416 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7420 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7424 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7428 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7432 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7436 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7440 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7441 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7442 and modifying how it is emptied.
7443 @end deffn
7444
7445 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7446 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7447 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7448 The image @var{type} may be one of
7449 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7450 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7451 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7455 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7456 @cindex vector_catch
7457 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7458 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7459
7460 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7461 @example
7462 0x01 Trap Reset
7463 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7464 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7465 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7466 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7467 0x20 reserved
7468 0x40 Trap IRQ
7469 0x80 Trap FIQ
7470 @end example
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7474 @cindex vector_table
7475
7476 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7477 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7478 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7479 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7480 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7481
7482 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7483
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7487 @cindex ARMv6
7488
7489 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7490 @cindex ARM11
7491
7492 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7493 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7494 which is enabled by default.
7495 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7496 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7497 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7498 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7499 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7500 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7504 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7505 which is enabled by default.
7506 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7507 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7508 @end deffn
7509
7510 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7511 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7512 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7513 they are disabled by default.
7514 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7518 @cindex vector_catch
7519 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7520 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7521 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7522
7523 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7524 for certain hardware events.
7525 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7526 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7527 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7531 @cindex ARMv7
7532
7533 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7534 @cindex Debug Access Port
7535 @cindex DAP
7536 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7537 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7538 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7539
7540 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7541 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7542 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7543 @end deffn
7544
7545 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7546 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7547 @end deffn
7548
7549 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7550 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7551 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7552 @end deffn
7553
7554 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7555 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7556 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7557 @end deffn
7558
7559 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7560 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7561 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7562 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7563 @end deffn
7564
7565 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7566 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7567 Defaulting to 0.
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7571 @cindex tracing
7572 @cindex SWO
7573 @cindex SWV
7574 @cindex TPIU
7575 @cindex ITM
7576 @cindex ETM
7577
7578 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7579 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7580 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7581
7582 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7583 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7584 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7585 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7586
7587 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7588 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7589 debugger adapter features.
7590
7591 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7592 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7593
7594 Command options:
7595 @itemize @minus
7596 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7597 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7598 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7599 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7600 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7601 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7602 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7603 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7604 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7605 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7606 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7607 coding;
7608 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7609 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7610 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7611 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7612 data is to be output via SWO;
7613 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7614 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7615 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7616 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7617 rate automatically.
7618 @end itemize
7619
7620 Example usage:
7621 @enumerate
7622 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7623 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7624 enough to:
7625 @example
7626 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7627 ...
7628 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7629 ...
7630 @end example
7631 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7632 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7633 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7634 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7635 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7636 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7637 @example
7638 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7639 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7640 @end example
7641 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7642 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7643 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7644 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7645 @example
7646 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7647 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7648 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7649 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7650 @end example
7651 @end enumerate
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7655 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7656 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7657 @end deffn
7658
7659 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7660 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7664 @cindex Cortex-M
7665
7666 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7667 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7668
7669 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7670 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7671 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7672 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7673 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7674 the step command leaves with the core running.
7675
7676 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7677 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7678 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7679
7680 Default is @option{auto}.
7681 @end deffn
7682
7683 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7684 @cindex vector_catch
7685 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7686 for certain hardware events.
7687
7688 Parameters request interception of
7689 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7690 @option{none} of them,
7691 or one or more of the following:
7692 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7693 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7694 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7695 @option{irq_err},
7696 @option{state_err},
7697 @option{chk_err}, or
7698 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7699 @option{reset}.
7700 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7701 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7702 are mapped to HardFault.
7703 UsageFault checks for
7704 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7705 must also be explicitly enabled.
7706
7707 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7708 @end deffn
7709
7710 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7711 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7712 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7713 @itemize @minus
7714 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7715 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7716 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7717 @end itemize
7718 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7719 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7720 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7721 the peripherals.
7722 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @section Intel Architecture
7726
7727 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7728 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7729 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7730 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7731 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7732 @itemize
7733 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7734 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7735 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7736 @end itemize
7737
7738 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7739 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7740 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7741
7742 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7743 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7744 @end deffn
7745
7746 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7747 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7748 @end deffn
7749
7750 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7751 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7752 @end deffn
7753
7754 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7755 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7756 @end deffn
7757
7758 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7759 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7763 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7764 @end deffn
7765
7766 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7767
7768 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7769 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7770
7771 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7772 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7773 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7774 @end deffn
7775 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7776 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7777
7778 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7779
7780 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7781 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7782 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @subsection Registers commands
7786 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7787 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7788 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7789
7790 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7791
7792 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7793 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7794 and "timer" groups.
7795
7796 @emph{example:}
7797 @example
7798 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7799 @end example
7800
7801
7802 @end deffn
7803 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7804 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7805
7806 @emph{group} can be "system",
7807 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7808 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7809 @end deffn
7810
7811 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7812 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7813 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7814 @cindex tracing
7815 @cindex libdcc
7816 @cindex DCC
7817 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7818 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7819 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7820 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7821
7822 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7823 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7824 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7825 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7826 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7827 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7828
7829 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7830 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7831 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7832 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7833 The target being debugged may
7834 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7835 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7836 each supported by a command:
7837
7838 @itemize
7839 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7840 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7841 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7842 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7843
7844 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7845 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7846 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7847
7848 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7849 and then displayed at any time.
7850 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7851
7852 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7853 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7854 @end itemize
7855
7856 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7857 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7858 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7859 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7860 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7861 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7862 does the same thing.
7863
7864 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7865 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7866 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7867 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7868 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7869
7870 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7871 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7872 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7876 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7877 in the order they triggered.
7878 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7879 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7880 history records.
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7884 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7885 they have been triggered.
7886 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7887 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7888 and associates it with that identifier.
7889
7890 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7891 are not related except by this command.
7892 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7893 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896
7897 @node JTAG Commands
7898 @chapter JTAG Commands
7899 @cindex JTAG Commands
7900 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7901 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7902 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7903 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7904 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7905
7906 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7907 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7908
7909 @itemize @bullet
7910 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7911 devices such as a CPUs.
7912 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7913 standard state machine (in parallel)
7914 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7915 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7916 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7917 while the reading previous ones.
7918 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7919 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7920 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7921 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7922 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7923 registers.
7924 @end itemize
7925
7926 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7927
7928 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7929 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7930 the order of TAP state transitions.
7931 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7932 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7933 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7934 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7935 these commands are not available.
7936
7937 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7938 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7939 that specify the entire register.
7940 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7941 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7942 The return value holds the original value of each
7943 of those fields.
7944
7945 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7946 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7947 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7948 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7949 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7950
7951 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7952 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7953
7954 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7955 in that state.
7956 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7957 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7958 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7959
7960 @quotation Warning
7961 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7962 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7963 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7964 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7965 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7966 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7967 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7968 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7969 @end quotation
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7973 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7974 This may be used for performance tuning.
7975
7976 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7977 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7978 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7979 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7980 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7981 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7985 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7986 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7987 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7988 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7989 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7990
7991 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7992 in that state.
7993 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7994 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7995 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7996
7997 @quotation Note
7998 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7999 register values, unlike data register values.
8000 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8001 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8002 @end quotation
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8006 Set values of reset signals.
8007 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8008 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8009 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8010 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8011 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8012 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8013 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8014
8015 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8016 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8017 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8018 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8019 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8020 instead of the TRST signal.
8021 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8022 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8023 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8024 with handlers for that event.
8025 @end deffn
8026
8027 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8028 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8029 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8030 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8031 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8032 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8033 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8034 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8035 The final state must also be stable.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8039 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8040 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8041 Instructions often need some time
8042 to execute before they take effect.
8043 @end deffn
8044
8045 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8046 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8047
8048 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8049 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8050 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8051 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8052 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8053 @end deffn
8054
8055 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8056 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8057 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8058 must also be enabled.
8059 Default is enabled.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @section TAP state names
8063 @cindex TAP state names
8064
8065 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8066 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8067 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8068 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8069
8070 @itemize @bullet
8071 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8072 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8073 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8074 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8075 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8076 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8077 through the data register
8078 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8079 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8080 for update or more shifting
8081 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8082 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8083 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8084 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8085 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8086 through the instruction register
8087 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8088 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8089 for update or more shifting
8090 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8091 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8092 @end itemize
8093
8094 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8095 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8096 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8097 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8098
8099 @itemize @bullet
8100 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8101 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8102 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8103 may not be as expected.
8104 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8105 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8106 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8107 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8108 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8109 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8110 @end itemize
8111
8112 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8113 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8114
8115 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8116 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8117 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8118 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8119
8120 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8121 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8122 @cindex SVF
8123
8124 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8125 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8126 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8127 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8128
8129 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8130 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8131 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8132 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8133 each command is logged before it is executed.
8134 @end deffn
8135
8136 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8137 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8138 @cindex XSVF
8139
8140 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8141 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8142 Xilinx devices.
8143 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8144 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8145
8146 @quotation Important
8147 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8148 @end quotation
8149
8150 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8151 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8152 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8153 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8154 that TAP.
8155 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8156 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8157 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8158 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8159 @end deffn
8160
8161 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8162 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8163 after building the software.
8164 You may find them useful:
8165
8166 @itemize
8167 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8168 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8169 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8170 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8171 @end itemize
8172
8173 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8174 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8175 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8176 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8177 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8178 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8179 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8180
8181
8182 @node Utility Commands
8183 @chapter Utility Commands
8184 @cindex Utility Commands
8185
8186 @section RAM testing
8187 @cindex RAM testing
8188
8189 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8190 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8191 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8192 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8193 hardware problems.
8194
8195 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8196 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8197 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8198 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8199
8200 Load the memory testing functions with
8201
8202 @example
8203 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8204 @end example
8205
8206 to get access to the following facilities:
8207
8208 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8209 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8210 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8214 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8215 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8216 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8217 @end deffn
8218
8219 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8220 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8221 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8222 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8223 @end deffn
8224
8225 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8226 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8227 @end deffn
8228
8229 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8230 @cindex Firmware recovery
8231
8232 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8233 devices recovery with JTAG.
8234
8235 For quickstart instructions run:
8236 @example
8237 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8238 @end example
8239
8240 @node TFTP
8241 @chapter TFTP
8242 @cindex TFTP
8243 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8244 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8245
8246 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8247 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8248 server (tftpd). For example,
8249
8250 @example
8251 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8252 @end example
8253
8254 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8255 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8256
8257 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8258 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8259 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8260 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8261
8262 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8263 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8264 @cindex GDB
8265 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8266 to debug remote targets.
8267 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8268
8269 @itemize
8270 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8271 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8272 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8273 as shown in this chapter.
8274 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8275 that also will probably need to be configured.
8276 @end itemize
8277
8278 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8279 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8280 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8281 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8282 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8283 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8284
8285 @section Connecting to GDB
8286 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8287 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8288 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8289 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8290 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8291
8292 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8293
8294 @enumerate
8295 @item
8296 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8297 @example
8298 target remote localhost:3333
8299 @end example
8300 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8301
8302 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8303 @example
8304 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8305 @end example
8306 @item
8307 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8308 @example
8309 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8310 @end example
8311 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8312 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8313 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8314 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8315 @end enumerate
8316
8317 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8318 GDB command line.
8319
8320 @section Sample GDB session startup
8321
8322 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8323 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8324 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8325 small ARM program.
8326 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8327 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8328
8329 @example
8330 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8331 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8332 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8333 ...
8334 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8335 ...
8336 (gdb) load
8337 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8338 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8339 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8340 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8341 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8342 (gdb) continue
8343 Continuing.
8344 ...
8345 @end example
8346
8347 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8348 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8349 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8350 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8351
8352 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8353
8354 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8355 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8356 packet size and the device's memory map.
8357 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8358 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8359 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8360
8361 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8362 You may need to set those up by hand.
8363 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8364 something like:
8365
8366 @example
8367 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8368 @end example
8369
8370 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8371
8372 @example
8373 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8374 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8375 @end example
8376
8377 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8378 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8379 do not have such restrictions.
8380
8381 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8382 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8383 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8384
8385 @example
8386 define hook-step
8387 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8388 end
8389 define hookpost-step
8390 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8391 end
8392 @end example
8393
8394 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8395 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8396 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8397 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8398
8399 @section Programming using GDB
8400 @cindex Programming using GDB
8401 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8402
8403 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8404 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8405 @example
8406 gdb_memory_map disable
8407 @end example
8408 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8409 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8410 working area.
8411
8412 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8413 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8414 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8415 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8416
8417 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8418 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8419
8420 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8421 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8422 @example
8423 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8424 @end example
8425
8426 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8427 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8428
8429 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8430 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8431 will be used.
8432
8433 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8434 script can be executed:
8435 @example
8436 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8437 @end example
8438
8439 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8440 can be used.
8441 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8442 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8443 @cindex SMP
8444 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8445 @itemize @bullet
8446 @item j - smp status request
8447 @item J - smp set request
8448 @end itemize
8449
8450 OpenOCD implements :
8451 @itemize @bullet
8452 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8453 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8454 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8455 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8456 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8457 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8458 @end itemize
8459
8460 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8461 @itemize @bullet
8462 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8463 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8464 @example
8465 set $_core 1
8466 #Jc01 packet is sent
8467 print $_core
8468 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8469 @end example
8470
8471 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8472 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8473
8474 @example
8475 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8476 define toggle0
8477 maint packet Jc0
8478 continue
8479 main packet Jc-1
8480 end
8481 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8482 define toggle1
8483 maint packet Jc1
8484 continue
8485 main packet Jc-1
8486 end
8487 @end example
8488 @end itemize
8489
8490 @section RTOS Support
8491 @cindex RTOS Support
8492 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8493
8494 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8495 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8496
8497 @* An example setup is below:
8498
8499 @example
8500 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8501 @end example
8502
8503 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8504
8505 Currently supported rtos's include:
8506 @itemize @bullet
8507 @item @option{eCos}
8508 @item @option{ThreadX}
8509 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8510 @item @option{linux}
8511 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8512 @item @option{embKernel}
8513 @item @option{mqx}
8514 @end itemize
8515
8516 @quotation Note
8517 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8518 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8519 @end quotation
8520
8521 @table @code
8522 @item eCos symbols
8523 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8524 @item ThreadX symbols
8525 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8526 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8527 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8528 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8529 @tex
8530 \begingroup
8531 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8532 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8533 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8534 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8535 \par
8536 \endgroup
8537 @end tex
8538 @item linux symbols
8539 init_task.
8540 @item ChibiOS symbols
8541 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8542 @item embKernel symbols
8543 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8544 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8545 @item mqx symbols
8546 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8547 @end table
8548
8549 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8550 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8551
8552 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8553 along with the project:
8554
8555 @table @code
8556 @item FreeRTOS
8557 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8558 @end table
8559
8560 @node Tcl Scripting API
8561 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8562 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8563 @cindex Tcl scripts
8564 @section API rules
8565
8566 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8567 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8568 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8569
8570 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8571 pair list and lists.
8572
8573 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8574 list.
8575
8576 @example
8577 > set foo(me) Duane
8578 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8579 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8580 > set foo(duck) Donald
8581 @end example
8582
8583 If one does this:
8584
8585 @example
8586 > set foo
8587 @end example
8588
8589 The result is:
8590
8591 @example
8592 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8593 @end example
8594
8595 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8596
8597 @verbatim
8598 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8599 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8600 }
8601 @end verbatim
8602
8603 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8604 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8605
8606 @section Internal low-level Commands
8607
8608 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8609 invoke directly.
8610
8611 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8612 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8613 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8614
8615 @itemize @bullet
8616 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8617
8618 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8619 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8620
8621 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8622 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8623
8624 Return information about the flash banks
8625
8626 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8627
8628 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8629 its execution. Example:
8630
8631 @example
8632 > capture "reset init"
8633 @end example
8634
8635 @end itemize
8636
8637 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8638 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8639 called "flash_banks".
8640
8641 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8642
8643 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8644 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8645 holds one of the following values:
8646
8647 @itemize @bullet
8648 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8649 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8650 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8651 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8652 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8653 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8654 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8655 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8656 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8657 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8658 @end itemize
8659
8660 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8661
8662 @quotation Note
8663 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8664 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8665 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8666 is jim, not real tcl).
8667 @end quotation
8668
8669 @section Tcl RPC server
8670 @cindex RPC
8671
8672 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8673 commands and receive the results.
8674
8675 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8676 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8677 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8678 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8679 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8680
8681 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8682 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8683 @command{capture} command.
8684
8685 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8686
8687 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8688 @cindex RPC Notifications
8689
8690 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8691 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8692
8693 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8694 in the following format.
8695
8696 @verbatim
8697 type target_event event [event-name]
8698 type target_state state [state-name]
8699 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8700 @end verbatim
8701
8702 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8703 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8704 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8705 Defaults to off.
8706
8707 @end deffn
8708
8709 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
8710 @cindex RPC trace output
8711
8712 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8713 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8714
8715 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
8716
8717 @verbatim
8718 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
8719 @end verbatim
8720
8721 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
8722 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
8723 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8724 Defaults to off.
8725
8726 See an example application here:
8727 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
8728
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @node FAQ
8732 @chapter FAQ
8733 @cindex faq
8734 @enumerate
8735 @anchor{faqrtck}
8736 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8737 @cindex RTCK
8738 @cindex adaptive clocking
8739 @*
8740
8741 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8742 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8743 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8744 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8745
8746 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8747 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8748 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8749 @enumerate
8750 @item
8751 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8752 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8753 @item
8754 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8755 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8756 @end enumerate
8757
8758 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8759 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8760 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8761 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8762 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8763 power).
8764
8765 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8766 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8767 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8768 ARM926 scenario).
8769 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8770 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8771 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8772
8773 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8774 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8775 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8776 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8777
8778 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8779
8780 In order to make use of this,
8781 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8782 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8783
8784 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8785 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8786 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8787 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8788 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8789
8790 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8791 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8792 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8793 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8794
8795 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8796 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8797 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8798 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8799 with a CPLD.
8800 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8801 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8802 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8803 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8804 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8805 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8806
8807 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8808
8809 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8810
8811 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8812 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8813 depending on the chips on your board.
8814 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8815 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8816 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8817
8818 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8819 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8820 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8821
8822 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8823 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8824 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8825 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8826
8827 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8828 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8829 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8830 this way.
8831
8832 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8833 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8834 clock rate.
8835 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8836 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8837 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8838
8839 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8840
8841 @example
8842 # Example: 1.234MHz
8843 adapter_khz 1234
8844 @end example
8845
8846
8847 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8848
8849 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8850 around Windows filenames.
8851
8852 @example
8853 > echo \a
8854
8855 > echo @{\a@}
8856 \a
8857 > echo "\a"
8858
8859 >
8860 @end example
8861
8862
8863 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8864
8865 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8866 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8867 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8868
8869 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8870 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8871 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8872
8873 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8874 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8875 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8876
8877 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8878
8879 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8880 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8881 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8882 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8883
8884 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8885 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8886 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8887
8888 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8889 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8890
8891 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8892 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8893 memory read caused data abort".
8894
8895 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8896 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8897 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8898 be done, feel free to add this here.
8899
8900 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8901 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8902 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8903 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8904 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8905 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8906 gracefully stops.
8907
8908 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8909 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8910 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8911
8912 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8913 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8914 bytes. Painful...
8915
8916
8917 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8918 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8919
8920 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8921 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8922 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8923 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8924 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8925 reset, everything else should work fine.
8926
8927 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8928 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8929 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8930 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8931
8932 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8933 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8934 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8935 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8936
8937 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8938
8939 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8940 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8941 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8942 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8943
8944 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8945 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8946 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8947 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8948
8949 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8950 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8951 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8952
8953 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8954 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8955
8956 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8957 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8958 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8959 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8960 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8961 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8962 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8963 clock frequency?
8964
8965 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8966 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8967 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8968 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8969 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8970
8971 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8972
8973 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8974 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8975 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8976 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8977 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8978 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8979 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8980
8981 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8982
8983 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8984 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8985 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8986 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8987
8988 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8989 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8990 particular order?
8991
8992 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8993 the same order used by the hardware.
8994
8995 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8996 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8997 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8998 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8999 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9000 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9001
9002 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9003 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9004 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9005 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9006
9007 @itemize @bullet
9008 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9009 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9010 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9011 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9012 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9013 @end itemize
9014
9015 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9016
9017 @itemize @bullet
9018 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9019 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9020 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9021 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9022 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9023 @end itemize
9024
9025
9026 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9027 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9028 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9029
9030 TODO.
9031
9032 @end enumerate
9033
9034 @node Tcl Crash Course
9035 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9036 @cindex Tcl
9037
9038 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9039 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9040 how the Tcl scripts work.
9041
9042 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9043 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9044 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9045 OpenOCD.
9046
9047 @section Tcl Rule #1
9048 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9049 @enumerate
9050 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9051 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9052 @end enumerate
9053
9054 The Tcl equal is this:
9055
9056 @enumerate
9057 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9058 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9059 @end enumerate
9060
9061 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9062 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9063
9064 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9065 There is a second pair of rules.
9066 @enumerate
9067 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9068 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9069 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9070 in Tcl.
9071 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9072 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9073 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9074 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9075 @end enumerate
9076
9077 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9078 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9079 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9080 Everything is a string}
9081
9082 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9083 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9084 difference is subtle.
9085 @enumerate
9086 @item Parse Time
9087 @item Evaluation Time
9088 @end enumerate
9089
9090 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9091 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9092 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9093
9094 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9095 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9096 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9097 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9098
9099 @itemize @bullet
9100 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9101 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9102 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9103 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9104 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9105 @example
9106 # bash example
9107 X=`date`
9108 echo "The Date is: $X"
9109 # Tcl example
9110 set X [date]
9111 puts "The Date is: $X"
9112 @end example
9113 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9114 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9115 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9116 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9117 is a string}
9118 @example
9119 set x "Dinner"
9120 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9121 @end example
9122 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9123 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9124 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9125 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9126 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9127 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9128 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9129 @end itemize
9130
9131 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9132
9133 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9134
9135 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9136
9137 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9138 the normal way.
9139
9140 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9141 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9142 line is immedatly executed.
9143
9144 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9145 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9146
9147 @subsection Command Execution
9148
9149 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9150 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9151 control flow operators.
9152
9153 Commands are executed like this:
9154
9155 @enumerate
9156 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9157 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9158 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9159 @end enumerate
9160
9161 It sort of works like this:
9162 @example
9163 for(;;)@{
9164 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9165
9166 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9167
9168 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9169 @}
9170 @end example
9171
9172 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9173 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9174 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9175 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9176 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9177 ``LookupCommand()''
9178
9179 @subsection The FOR command
9180
9181 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9182 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9183 command just like any other command.
9184
9185 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9186 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9187 are:
9188
9189 @enumerate 0
9190 @item The ascii text 'for'
9191 @item The start text
9192 @item The test expression
9193 @item The next text
9194 @item The body text
9195 @end enumerate
9196
9197 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9198 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9199 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9200 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9201
9202 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9203 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9204
9205 @example
9206 int
9207 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9208 int *argc,
9209 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9210 @end example
9211
9212 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9213 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9214 still operates in the same basic way.
9215
9216 @subsection FOR command implementation
9217
9218 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9219 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9220
9221 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9222
9223 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9224
9225 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9226 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9227 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9228
9229 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9230 expression and returns a value.
9231
9232 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9233 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9234 @example
9235 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9236
9237 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9238
9239 int
9240 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9241 int argc,
9242 char **argv )
9243 @{
9244 if( argc != 5 )@{
9245 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9246 return ERROR;
9247 @}
9248
9249 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9250
9251 // Execute the start statement.
9252 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9253
9254 // Top of loop test
9255 for(;;)@{
9256 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9257 if( i == 0 )
9258 break;
9259
9260 // Execute the body
9261 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9262
9263 // Execute the LOOP part
9264 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9265 @}
9266
9267 // Return no error
9268 SetResult( interp, "" );
9269 return SUCCESS;
9270 @}
9271 @end example
9272
9273 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9274 in the same basic way.
9275
9276 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9277
9278 @subsection source and find commands
9279 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9280 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9281 @*Remember the parsing rules
9282 @enumerate
9283 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9284 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9285 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9286 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9287 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9288 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9289 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9290 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9291 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9292 @end enumerate
9293 @subsection format command
9294 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9295 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9296 @b{sprintf()}.
9297 @b{Example}
9298 @example
9299 set x 6
9300 set y 7
9301 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9302 @end example
9303 @enumerate
9304 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9305 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9306 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9307 @* Refer to Rule #1
9308 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9309 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9310 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9311 @end enumerate
9312 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9313 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9314 @example
9315 #1 Good
9316 proc someproc @{@} @{
9317 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9318 @}
9319 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9320 #2 Good - no variables
9321 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9322 #3 Good Curly Braces
9323 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9324 puts "Time: [date]"
9325 @}
9326 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9327 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9328 @end example
9329 @enumerate
9330 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9331 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9332 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9333 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9334 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9335 command.
9336 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9337 @*There are 4 examples:
9338 @enumerate
9339 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9340 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9341 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9342 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9343 @end enumerate
9344
9345 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9346 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9347 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9348
9349 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9350 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9351 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9352 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9353 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9354 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9355 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9356 @end enumerate
9357 @subsection Global Variables
9358 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9359 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9360 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9361 @example
9362 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9363 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9364 global x #Global variable X
9365 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9366 @}
9367 @end example
9368 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9369 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9370 @example
9371 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9372 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9373 # Create var name
9374 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9375 # Make it a global
9376 global $vn
9377 # Set it.
9378 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9379 @}
9380 @end example
9381 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9382 @example
9383 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9384 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9385 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9386 @}
9387 @end example
9388
9389 @include fdl.texi
9390
9391 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9392 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9393 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9394 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9395 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9396 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9397
9398 @printindex cp
9399
9400 @node Command and Driver Index
9401 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9402 @printindex fn
9403
9404 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)